blob: 0d17e7dbe10a2b99d1055803b6367fc7af822be2 [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkb75190d2012-01-19 10:58:21 +01002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2012
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
5# See file CREDITS for list of people who contributed to this
6# project.
7#
8# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
10# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of
11# the License, or (at your option) any later version.
12#
13# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16# GNU General Public License for more details.
17#
18# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
20# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston,
21# MA 02111-1307 USA
22#
23
24Summary:
25========
26
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000027This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000028Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
29processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
30initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
31code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000032
33The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
35header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000036support booting of Linux images.
37
38Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
39configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
40implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
41add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
42code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
43load and run it dynamically.
44
45
46Status:
47=======
48
49In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000051"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
52
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000053In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010054who contributed the specific port. The MAINTAINERS file lists board
55maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000057
58Where to get help:
59==================
60
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000061In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
62U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050063<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
64on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
65Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
66http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000067
68
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010069Where to get source code:
70=========================
71
72The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
73git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
74http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
75
76The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020077any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010078available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
79directory.
80
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010081Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010082ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
83
84
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000085Where we come from:
86===================
87
88- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000090- clean up code
91- make it easier to add custom boards
92- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
93- extend functions, especially:
94 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
95 * S-Record download
96 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020097 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000098- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000099- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000100- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +0200101- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000102
103
104Names and Spelling:
105===================
106
107The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
108"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
109in source files etc.). Example:
110
111 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
112
113File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
114
115 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
116
117 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
118
119Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
120the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
121
122 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
123 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000124
125
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000126Versioning:
127===========
128
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200129Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
130were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
131into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
132names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
133Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
134releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000135
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200136Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000137 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200138 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
139 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000140
141
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000142Directory Hierarchy:
143====================
144
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500145/arch Architecture specific files
146 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
147 /cpu CPU specific files
148 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
149 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000150 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200151 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
152 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500153 /arm925t Files specific to ARM 925 CPUs
154 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
155 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
156 /ixp Files specific to Intel XScale IXP CPUs
157 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
158 /s3c44b0 Files specific to Samsung S3C44B0 CPUs
159 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
160 /lib Architecture specific library files
161 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
162 /cpu CPU specific files
163 /lib Architecture specific library files
164 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
165 /cpu CPU specific files
166 /lib Architecture specific library files
Graeme Russfea25722011-04-13 19:43:28 +1000167 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500168 /cpu CPU specific files
169 /lib Architecture specific library files
170 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
171 /cpu CPU specific files
172 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
173 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
174 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
175 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
176 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
177 /lib Architecture specific library files
178 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
179 /cpu CPU specific files
180 /lib Architecture specific library files
181 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
182 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200183 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Xiangfu Liu80421fc2011-10-12 12:24:06 +0800184 /xburst Files specific to Ingenic XBurst CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500185 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000186 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
187 /cpu CPU specific files
188 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
189 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500190 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
191 /cpu CPU specific files
192 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200193 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500194 /cpu CPU specific files
195 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
196 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
197 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
198 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
199 /mpc8220 Files specific to Freescale MPC8220 CPUs
200 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
201 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
202 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
203 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
204 /lib Architecture specific library files
205 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
206 /cpu CPU specific files
207 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
208 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
209 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
210 /lib Architecture specific library files
211 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
212 /cpu CPU specific files
213 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
214 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
215 /lib Architecture specific library files
216/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
217/board Board dependent files
218/common Misc architecture independent functions
219/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
220/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
221/drivers Commonly used device drivers
222/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
223/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
224/include Header Files
225/lib Files generic to all architectures
226 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
227 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
228 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
229/net Networking code
230/post Power On Self Test
231/rtc Real Time Clock drivers
232/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000233
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000234Software Configuration:
235=======================
236
237Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
238rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
239
240There are two classes of configuration variables:
241
242* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
243 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
244 "CONFIG_".
245
246* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
247 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
248 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200249 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000250
251Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
252identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
253do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
254links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
255as an example here.
256
257
258Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
259---------------------------------------------------
260
261For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
262configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_config".
263
264Example: For a TQM823L module type:
265
266 cd u-boot
267 make TQM823L_config
268
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200269For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000270e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_config". And also configure the cogent
271directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
272
273
274Configuration Options:
275----------------------
276
277Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
278such information is kept in a configuration file
279"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
280
281Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
282"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
283
284
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000285Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
286kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
287build a config tool - later.
288
289
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000290The following options need to be configured:
291
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500292- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000293
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500294- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200295
296- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100297 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000298
299- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
300 Define exactly one of
301 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
302--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
303 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
304 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
305
306- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
307 Define exactly one of
308 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
309
310- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
311 Define one or more of
312 CONFIG_CMA302
313
314- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
315 Define one or more of
316 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200317 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000318 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
319
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000320- Board flavour: (if CONFIG_MPC8260ADS is defined)
321 CONFIG_ADSTYPE
322 Possible values are:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200323 CONFIG_SYS_8260ADS - original MPC8260ADS
324 CONFIG_SYS_8266ADS - MPC8266ADS
325 CONFIG_SYS_PQ2FADS - PQ2FADS-ZU or PQ2FADS-VR
326 CONFIG_SYS_8272ADS - MPC8272ADS
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000327
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530328- Marvell Family Member
329 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
330 multiple fs option at one time
331 for marvell soc family
332
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000333- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000334 Define exactly one of
335 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000336
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200337- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000338 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
339 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000340 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
341 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000342 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
343 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000344
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000345- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200346 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
347 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000348 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000349 See doc/README.MPC866
350
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200351 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000352
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000353 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
354 of relying on the correctness of the configured
355 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
356 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
357 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200358 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000359
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100360 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
361
362 Define this option if you want to enable the
363 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
364
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600365- 85xx CPU Options:
366 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
367
368 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
369 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
370 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
371
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500372 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
373
374 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
375 tree nodes for the given platform.
376
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000377 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
378
379 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
380 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
381 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
382 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
383 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
384 purpose.
385
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000386 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
387
388 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
389 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
390 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
391
392 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
393 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
394
395 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
396 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
397
398 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
399 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
400 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
401 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
402
403 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
404 this erratum.
405
406 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
407
408 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
409 according to the A004510 workaround.
410
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000411- Generic CPU options:
412 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
413
414 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
415 values is arch specific.
416
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100417- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200418 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100419
420 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
421 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
422 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
423
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200424 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200425
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100426 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
427 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200428 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100429 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200430
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200431- MIPS CPU options:
432 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
433
434 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
435 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
436 relocation.
437
438 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
439
440 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
441 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
442 Possible values are:
443 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
444 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
445 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
446 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
447 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
448 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
449 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
450 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
451
452 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
453
454 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
455 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
456
457 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
458
459 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
460 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
461 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
462
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000463- ARM options:
464 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
465
466 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
467 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
468
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000469 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
470
471 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
472 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
473 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
474 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
475 GCC.
476
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000477- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000478 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
479
480 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
481 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
482 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
483 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
484 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
485 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
486 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000487 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100488 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000489 default environment.
490
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000491 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
492
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200493 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000494 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
495 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
496
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400497 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200498
499 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400500 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
501 concepts).
502
503 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
504 * New libfdt-based support
505 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500506 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400507
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200508 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
509 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
510 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
511 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200512 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600513 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200514
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200515 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
516 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500517
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600518 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
519
520 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
521 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000522
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500523 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
524
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200525 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500526 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
527
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200528 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
529
530 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
531 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
532 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
533 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
534 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
535 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
536
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000537 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
538
539 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
540 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
541 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
542 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
543 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
544 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
545 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
546
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100547- vxWorks boot parameters:
548
549 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
550 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
551 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
552
553 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
554 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
555 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
556 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
557
558 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
559
560 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
561
562 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
563 the defaults discussed just above.
564
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000565- Cache Configuration:
566 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
567 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
568 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
569
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000570- Cache Configuration for ARM:
571 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
572 controller
573 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
574 controller register space
575
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000576- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200577 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000578
579 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
580
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200581 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000582
583 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
584
585 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
586
587 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
588 the clock speed of the UARTs.
589
590 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
591
592 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
593 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
594 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
595
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000596 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
597
598 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
599 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
600 this variable to initialize the extra register.
601
602 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
603
604 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
605 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
606 variable to flush the UART at init time.
607
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000608
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000609- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000610 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
611 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
612 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
613 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000614
615 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
616 port routines must be defined elsewhere
617 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
618
619 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
620 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000621 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000622 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
623 (default big endian)
624 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
625 rectangle fill
626 (cf. smiLynxEM)
627 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
628 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
629 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
630 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000631 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
632 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000633 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
634 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000635 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000636 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
637 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
638 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
639 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
640 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
641 (i.e. i8042_getc)
642 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
643 (requires blink timer
644 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200645 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000646 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
647 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500648 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000649 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
650 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000651 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
652 linux_logo.h for logo.
653 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000654 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200655 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000656 the logo
657
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000658 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
659 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
660 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000661
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000662 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
663 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
664 the "silent" environment variable. See
665 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000666
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000667- Console Baudrate:
668 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
669 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200670 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
671 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000672
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100673- Console Rx buffer length
674 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
675 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100676 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100677 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
678 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
679 the SMC.
680
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000681- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200682 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
683 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
684 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
685 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
686 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
687 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
688 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200689 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200690 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000691
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200692 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
693 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000694
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000695- Safe printf() functions
696 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
697 the printf() functions. These are defined in
698 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
699 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
700 If this option is not given then these functions will
701 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
702 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
703
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000704- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
705 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
706 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
707
708 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
709 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
710 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
711 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
712 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
713 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
714 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
715 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
716 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
717 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
718 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
719 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
720
721- Autoboot Command:
722 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
723 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
724 define a command string that is automatically executed
725 when no character is read on the console interface
726 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
727
728 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000729 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
730 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
731 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000732
733 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000734 The value of these goes into the environment as
735 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
736 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200737 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000738
739- Pre-Boot Commands:
740 CONFIG_PREBOOT
741
742 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
743 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
744 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
745 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
746 entering interactive mode.
747
748 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
749 automatically generated or modified. For an example
750 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
751 modified when the user holds down a certain
752 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
753 booting the systems
754
755- Serial Download Echo Mode:
756 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
757 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
758 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
759 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
760 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
761 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
762 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
763
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500764- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000765 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
766 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200767 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000768
769- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500770 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
771 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000772 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
773 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500774 and augmenting with additional #define's
775 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000776
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500777 The default command configuration includes all commands
778 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000779
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500780 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500781 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
782 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
783 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
784 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
785 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
786 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
787 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500788 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500789 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
790 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
791 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600792 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
793 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
794 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
795 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500796 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
797 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500798 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500799 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
800 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500801 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500802 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500803 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
804 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT partition support
805 CONFIG_CMD_FDOS * Dos diskette Support
806 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
807 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -0500808 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +0000809 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500810 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
811 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
812 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
813 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
814 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all found images
815 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500816 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500817 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
818 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
819 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
820 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Mike Frysinger1ba7fd22010-12-26 12:34:49 -0500821 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +0000822 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
823 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500824 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
825 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400826 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM print md5 message digest
827 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500828 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
829 loop, loopw, mtest
830 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
831 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
832 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +0100833 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500834 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
835 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600836 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000837 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500838 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
839 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
840 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
841 host
842 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
843 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
844 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
845 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
846 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
847 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
848 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
849 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
850 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -0700851 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Alexander Hollerc6b1ee62011-01-18 09:48:08 +0100852 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400853 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +0200854 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500855 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +0000856 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +0000857 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Che-liang Chiouca366d02011-10-06 23:40:48 +0000858 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500859 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500860 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +0000861 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000862
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000863
864 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
865 support you can write:
866
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500867 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
868 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000869
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400870 Other Commands:
871 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000872
873 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500874 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000875 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
876 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
877 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
878 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
879 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
880 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000881
882
883 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
884
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000885- Device tree:
886 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
887 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
888 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
889 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
890 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
891 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
892
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000893 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
894 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000895
896 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
897 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
898 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
899 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
900 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
901 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000902
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000903 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
904 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
905 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
906 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
907
908 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
909
910 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
911 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
912 still use the individual files if you need something more
913 exotic.
914
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000915- Watchdog:
916 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
917 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000918 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
919 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
920 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
921 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
922 available, then no further board specific code should
923 be needed to use it.
924
925 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
926 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
927 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
928 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000929
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000930- U-Boot Version:
931 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
932 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
933 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
934 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e52012-08-13 15:01:14 +0200935 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
936 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000937
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000938- Real-Time Clock:
939
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500940 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000941 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
942 following options:
943
944 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
945 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +0000946 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000947 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +0000948 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000949 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +0000950 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +0000951 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +0100952 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +0000953 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200954 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +0200955 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
956 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000957
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +0000958 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
959 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
960
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600961- GPIO Support:
962 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
963 CONFIG_PCA953X_INFO - enable pca953x info command
964
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +0000965 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
966 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
967 pins supported by a particular chip.
968
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600969 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
970 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
971
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000972- Timestamp Support:
973
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000974 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
975 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
976 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500977 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000978
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000979- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
980 Zero or more of the following:
981 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
982 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
983 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
984 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
985 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
986 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
987 disk/part_efi.c
988 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000989
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100990 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
991 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000992 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000993
994- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000995 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
996 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000997
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000998 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
999 be performed by calling the function
1000 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1001 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001002
1003- ATAPI Support:
1004 CONFIG_ATAPI
1005
1006 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1007
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001008- LBA48 Support
1009 CONFIG_LBA48
1010
1011 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001012 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001013 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1014 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1015
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001016 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001017 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1018 Default is 32bit.
1019
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001020- SCSI Support:
1021 At the moment only there is only support for the
1022 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1023 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1024
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001025 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1026 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1027 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001028 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1029 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001030 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001031
1032- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001033 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001034 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1035
1036 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1037 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1038 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1039 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1040
1041 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1042 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1043 example with the "sspi" command.
1044
1045 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1046 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1047 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001048
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001049 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001050 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001051
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001052 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1053 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001054 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001055 write routine for first time initialisation.
1056
1057 CONFIG_TULIP
1058 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1059 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1060 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1061
1062 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1063 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1064
1065 CONFIG_NS8382X
1066 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1067
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001068- NETWORK Support (other):
1069
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001070 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1071 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1072
1073 CONFIG_RMII
1074 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1075
1076 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1077 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1078 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1079
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001080 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1081 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1082
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001083 CONFIG_DRIVER_LAN91C96
1084 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1085
1086 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1087 Define this to hold the physical address
1088 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1089
1090 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1091 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1092
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001093 CONFIG_DRIVER_SMC91111
1094 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1095
1096 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1097 Define this to hold the physical address
1098 of the device (I/O space)
1099
1100 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1101 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1102
1103 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1104 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1105 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1106
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001107 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1108 Support for davinci emac
1109
1110 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1111 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1112
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001113 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1114 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1115
1116 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1117 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1118 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1119 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1120 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1121 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1122 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1123 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1124
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001125 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001126 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1127
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001128 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001129 Define this to hold the physical address
1130 of the device (I/O space)
1131
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001132 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001133 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1134
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001135 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001136 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1137 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001138 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001139
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001140 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1141 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1142
1143 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1144 Define the number of ports to be used
1145
1146 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1147 Define the ETH PHY's address
1148
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001149 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1150 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1151
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001152- TPM Support:
1153 CONFIG_GENERIC_LPC_TPM
1154 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1155 per system is supported at this time.
1156
1157 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1158 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1159 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1160 0xfed40000.
1161
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001162- USB Support:
1163 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001164 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001165 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1166 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001167 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001168 storage devices.
1169 Note:
1170 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1171 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001172 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1173 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1174 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001175 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1176 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001177 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1178 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1179 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001180 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1181 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001182 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001183 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1184 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001185
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001186 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1187 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1188
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001189- USB Device:
1190 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1191 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1192 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001193 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001194 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1195 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001196 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001197 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1198 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1199 a Linux host by
1200 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1201 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1202 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1203 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001204
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001205 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1206 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001207
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001208 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1209 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1210 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001211
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301212 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1213 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1214 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1215 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1216 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1217 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1218 speed.
1219
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001220 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001221 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1222 be set to usbtty.
1223
1224 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001225 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001226 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001227 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001228
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001229 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001230 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001231 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001232
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001233 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001234 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001235 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001236 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1237 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1238 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1239
1240 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1241 Define this string as the name of your company for
1242 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001243
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001244 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1245 Define this string as the name of your product
1246 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1247
1248 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1249 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1250 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1251 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1252 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001253
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001254 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1255 Define this as the unique Product ID
1256 for your device
1257 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001258
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001259- ULPI Layer Support:
1260 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1261 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1262 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1263 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1264 viewport is supported.
1265 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1266 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001267
1268- MMC Support:
1269 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1270 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1271 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1272 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001273 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1274 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001275
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001276 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1277 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1278
1279 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1280 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1281
1282 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1283 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1284
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001285- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1286 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1287 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1288 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1289
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001290 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1291 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001292 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1293
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001294 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001295 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1296 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1297
1298 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001299 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001300 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1301 have not defined a custom partition
1302
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001303- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1304 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001305
1306 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1307 file in FAT formatted partition.
1308
1309 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1310 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001311
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001312- Keyboard Support:
1313 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1314
1315 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1316 support
1317
1318 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1319 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1320 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1321 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1322 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1323
1324- Video support:
1325 CONFIG_VIDEO
1326
1327 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1328 video).
1329
1330 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1331
1332 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1333
1334 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001335 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001336 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1337 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1338 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001339
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001340 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001341 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001342 are possible:
1343 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001344 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001345
1346 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1347 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1348 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1349 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1350 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1351 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1352 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001353 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1354
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001355 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001356 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001357
1358
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001359 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001360 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001361 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1362 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1363
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001364 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001365 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001366 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1367 support, and should also define these other macros:
1368
1369 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1370 CONFIG_VIDEO
1371 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1372 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1373 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1374 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1375 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1376 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1377
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001378 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1379 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1380 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1381 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001382
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001383- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001384 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001385
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001386 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1387 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1388 defined in your board-specific files.
1389 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001390
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001391- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1392
1393 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1394 display); also select one of the supported displays
1395 by defining one of these:
1396
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001397 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1398
1399 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1400
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001401 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001402
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001403 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001404
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001405 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001406
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001407 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1408 Active, color, single scan.
1409
1410 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1411
1412 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001413 Active, color, single scan.
1414
1415 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1416
1417 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1418 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1419
1420 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1421
1422 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1423 Active, color, single scan.
1424
1425 CONFIG_HLD1045
1426
1427 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1428 Active, color, single scan.
1429
1430 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1431
1432 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1433 or
1434 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1435 or
1436 Hitachi SP14Q002
1437
1438 320x240. Black & white.
1439
1440 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001441 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001442
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001443- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001444
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001445 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1446 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1447 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001448 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001449 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1450 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1451 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1452 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001453
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001454 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1455
1456 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1457 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1458 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1459 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1460 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1461 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1462
1463 Example:
1464 setenv splashpos m,m
1465 => image at center of screen
1466
1467 setenv splashpos 30,20
1468 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1469
1470 setenv splashpos -10,m
1471 => vertically centered image
1472 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1473
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001474- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1475
1476 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1477 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1478 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1479
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001480- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1481
1482 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1483 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1484 bmp command.
1485
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001486- Do compresssing for memory range:
1487 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1488
1489 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1490 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1491
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001492- Compression support:
1493 CONFIG_BZIP2
1494
1495 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1496 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1497 compressed images are supported.
1498
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001499 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001500 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001501 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001502
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001503 CONFIG_LZMA
1504
1505 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1506 images is included.
1507
1508 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1509 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1510 formula:
1511
1512 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1513
1514 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1515 and Literal pos bits.
1516
1517 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1518 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1519 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1520 a very small buffer.
1521
1522 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1523 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001524 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001525
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001526- MII/PHY support:
1527 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1528
1529 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1530
1531 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1532
1533 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1534
1535 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1536
1537 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001538 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001539
1540 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1541
1542 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1543 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1544 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1545 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1546
1547 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1548
1549 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1550 command issued before MII status register can be read
1551
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001552- Ethernet address:
1553 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001554 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001555 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1556 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001557 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1558 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001559
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001560 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1561 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001562 is not determined automatically.
1563
1564- IP address:
1565 CONFIG_IPADDR
1566
1567 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001568 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001569 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001570 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001571
1572- Server IP address:
1573 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1574
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001575 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001576 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001577 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001578
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001579 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1580
1581 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1582 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1583
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001584- Gateway IP address:
1585 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1586
1587 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1588 default router where packets to other networks are
1589 sent to.
1590 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1591
1592- Subnet mask:
1593 CONFIG_NETMASK
1594
1595 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1596 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1597 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1598 forwarded through a router.
1599 (Environment variable "netmask")
1600
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001601- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1602 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1603
1604 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1605 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001606 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001607 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1608 multicast group.
1609
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001610- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1611 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1612
1613 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1614 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1615 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1616 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1617 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1618 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1619 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1620 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001621 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001622
1623 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1624 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1625 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1626 4th and following
1627 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1628
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001629- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001630 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1631 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001632
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001633 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1634 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1635 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1636 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1637 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1638 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1639 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1640 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1641 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1642 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1643 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1644 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001645 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001646
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001647 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1648 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001649
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001650 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1651 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1652 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1653 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1654 is not available.
1655
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001656 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1657 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1658 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1659 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1660 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1661 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1662 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001663 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001664
1665 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1666 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1667 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001668 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001669 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1670 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001671
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001672 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1673
1674 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1675 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1676 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1677 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1678 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1679 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1680 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1681 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1682 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1683 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1684 this delay.
1685
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001686 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1687 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1688 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1689 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1690 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1691
1692 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1693
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001694 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001695 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001696
1697 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1698
1699 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1700
1701 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1702 of the device.
1703
1704 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1705
1706 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1707 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001708 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001709
1710 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1711
1712 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1713 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1714
1715 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1716
1717 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1718
1719 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1720
1721 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1722
1723 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1724
1725 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1726
1727 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1728
1729 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1730 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1731
1732 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1733
1734 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1735
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001736- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
1737
1738 Several configurations allow to display the current
1739 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1740 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1741 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1742 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1743 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
1744 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
1745 feature in U-Boot.
1746
1747- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
1748
1749 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
1750 on those systems that support this (optional)
1751 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
1752
1753- I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C | CONFIG_SOFT_I2C
1754
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001755 These enable I2C serial bus commands. Defining either of
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001756 (but not both of) CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C will
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001757 include the appropriate I2C driver for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001758
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001759 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001760 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001761 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
1762 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001763 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001764
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001765 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001766
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001767 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C configures u-boot to use a software (aka
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001768 bit-banging) driver instead of CPM or similar hardware
1769 support for I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001770
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001771 There are several other quantities that must also be
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001772 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001773
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001774 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001775 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001776 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001777 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001778
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001779 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02001780 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001781 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
1782 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
1783 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001784
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05001785 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
1786
1787 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1788 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1789 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
1790 commands until the slave device responds.
1791
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001792 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001793
1794 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SOFT_I2C)
1795 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1796 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001797
1798 I2C_INIT
1799
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001800 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001801 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001802
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001803 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001804
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001805 I2C_PORT
1806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001807 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
1808 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
1809 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001810
1811 I2C_ACTIVE
1812
1813 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1814 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1815 define can be null.
1816
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001817 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1818
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001819 I2C_TRISTATE
1820
1821 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1822 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1823 define can be null.
1824
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001825 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1826
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001827 I2C_READ
1828
1829 Code that returns TRUE if the I2C data line is high,
1830 FALSE if it is low.
1831
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001832 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1833
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001834 I2C_SDA(bit)
1835
1836 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1837 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1838
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001839 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001840 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001841 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001842
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001843 I2C_SCL(bit)
1844
1845 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1846 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1847
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001848 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001849 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001850 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001851
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001852 I2C_DELAY
1853
1854 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1855 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001856 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001857 like:
1858
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001859 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001860
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04001861 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
1862
1863 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
1864 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
1865 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
1866 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
1867
1868 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
1869 the generic GPIO functions.
1870
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001871 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001872
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001873 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1874 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1875 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
1876 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
1877 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
1878 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
1879 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
1880 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001881
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04001882 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
1883
1884 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
1885 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
1886 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
1887 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
1888 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
1889 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
1890 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
1891 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
1892
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001893 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
1894
1895 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
1896 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
1897 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
1898
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001899 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
1900
1901 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001902 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
1903 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001904 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
1905
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001906 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001907
1908 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001909 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05001910 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
1911 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001912
1913 e.g.
1914 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001915 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001916
1917 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
1918
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001919 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001920 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001921
1922 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
1923
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001924 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001925
1926 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
1927 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
1928
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001929 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001930
1931 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
1932 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
1933
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001934 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001935
1936 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
1937 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
1938
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001939 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07001940
1941 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
1942 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
1943 specified DTT device.
1944
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001945 CONFIG_FSL_I2C
1946
1947 Define this option if you want to use Freescale's I2C driver in
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001948 drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c.
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001949
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001950 CONFIG_I2C_MUX
1951
1952 Define this option if you have I2C devices reached over 1 .. n
1953 I2C Muxes like the pca9544a. This option addes a new I2C
1954 Command "i2c bus [muxtype:muxaddr:muxchannel]" which adds a
1955 new I2C Bus to the existing I2C Busses. If you select the
1956 new Bus with "i2c dev", u-bbot sends first the commandos for
1957 the muxes to activate this new "bus".
1958
1959 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS must be also defined, to use this
1960 feature!
1961
1962 Example:
1963 Adding a new I2C Bus reached over 2 pca9544a muxes
1964 The First mux with address 70 and channel 6
1965 The Second mux with address 71 and channel 4
1966
1967 => i2c bus pca9544a:70:6:pca9544a:71:4
1968
1969 Use the "i2c bus" command without parameter, to get a list
1970 of I2C Busses with muxes:
1971
1972 => i2c bus
1973 Busses reached over muxes:
1974 Bus ID: 2
1975 reached over Mux(es):
1976 pca9544a@70 ch: 4
1977 Bus ID: 3
1978 reached over Mux(es):
1979 pca9544a@70 ch: 6
1980 pca9544a@71 ch: 4
1981 =>
1982
1983 If you now switch to the new I2C Bus 3 with "i2c dev 3"
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00001984 u-boot first sends the command to the mux@70 to enable
1985 channel 6, and then the command to the mux@71 to enable
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001986 the channel 4.
1987
1988 After that, you can use the "normal" i2c commands as
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00001989 usual to communicate with your I2C devices behind
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001990 the 2 muxes.
1991
1992 This option is actually implemented for the bitbanging
1993 algorithm in common/soft_i2c.c and for the Hardware I2C
1994 Bus on the MPC8260. But it should be not so difficult
1995 to add this option to other architectures.
1996
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06001997 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
1998
1999 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2000 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2001 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2002 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2003 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2004 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2005 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002006
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002007- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2008
2009 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2010 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2011 D/As on the SACSng board)
2012
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002013 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2014
2015 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2016 only SH7757 is supported.
2017
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002018 CONFIG_SPI_X
2019
2020 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2021 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2022
2023 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2024
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002025 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2026 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2027 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2028 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2029 defined, the board configuration must define several
2030 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2031 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002032
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002033 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2034
2035 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2036 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2037 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002038 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002039 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2040
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002041 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2042
2043 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002044 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002045
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002046- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2047
2048 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2049
2050 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2051
2052 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2053 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2054
2055 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2056
2057 Enables support for FPGA family.
2058 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2059
2060 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002061
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002062 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002063
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002064 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002065
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002066 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002067
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002068 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002069
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002070 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2071 status by the configuration function. This option
2072 will require a board or device specific function to
2073 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002074
2075 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2076
2077 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2078 configuration driver.
2079
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002080 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002081 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2082
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002083 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002084
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002085 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2086 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2087 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2088 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002089
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002090 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002091
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002092 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2093 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2094 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002095 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002096
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002097 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002098
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002099 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002100 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002101
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002102 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002103
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002104 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002105 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002106
2107- Configuration Management:
2108 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2109
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002110 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2111 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002112
2113- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2114
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002115 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2116 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002117 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002118 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2119 protects these variables from casual modification by
2120 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2121 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002122 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002123
2124 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2125 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002126 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002127 these parameters.
2128
2129 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2130 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002131 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002132 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2133 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2134 read-only.]
2135
2136- Protected RAM:
2137 CONFIG_PRAM
2138
2139 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2140 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2141 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2142 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2143 this default value by defining an environment
2144 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2145 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2146 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2147 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2148 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2149 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2150 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2151
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002152 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002153 saveenv
2154
2155 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2156 either, which results in a memory region that will
2157 not be affected by reboots.
2158
2159 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2160 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2161 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2162 following board configurations are known to be
2163 "pRAM-clean":
2164
2165 ETX094, IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2166 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON, LANTEC,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002167 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002168
2169- Error Recovery:
2170 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2171
2172 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2173 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2174 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002175 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002176 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2177 useful during development since you can try to debug
2178 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2179
2180 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2181
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002182 This variable defines the number of retries for
2183 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2184 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2185 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002186
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002187 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2188
2189 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2190
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002191 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2192
2193 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2194 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2195 try longer timeout such as
2196 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2197
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002198- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002199 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002200
2201 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2202
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002203 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2204 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002205
2206
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002207 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002208
2209 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2210 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2211 powerful command line syntax like
2212 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2213 constructs ("shell scripts").
2214
2215 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2216 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2217
2218
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002219 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002220
2221 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2222 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2223 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2224
2225 Note:
2226
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002227 In the current implementation, the local variables
2228 space and global environment variables space are
2229 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2230 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2231 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2232 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2233 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002234
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002235 Global environment variables are those you use
2236 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2237 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2238 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002239
2240 To store commands and special characters in a
2241 variable, please use double quotation marks
2242 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2243 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2244 symbols.
2245
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002246- Commandline Editing and History:
2247 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2248
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002249 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002250 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002251
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002252- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002253 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2254
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002255 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2256 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002257 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002258
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002259 For example, place something like this in your
2260 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002261
2262 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2263 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2264 "myvar2=value2\0"
2265
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002266 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2267 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2268 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2269 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002270 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002271 You better know what you are doing here.
2272
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002273 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2274 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002275 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002276 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002277
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002278 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2279
2280 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2281 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2282 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2283
2284 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2285
2286 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2287 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2288 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2289 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2290 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2291
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002292- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002293 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2294
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002295 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2296 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2297 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002298
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002299- Serial Flash support
2300 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2301
2302 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2303 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2304
2305 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2306 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2307 commands.
2308
2309 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2310 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2311 flash is present on the system.
2312
2313 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2314 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2315 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2316 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2317
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002318- SystemACE Support:
2319 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2320
2321 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2322 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002323 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002324 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002325
2326 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002327 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002328
2329 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2330 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2331
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002332- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2333 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2334
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002335 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002336 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002337 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002338 number generator is used.
2339
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002340 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2341 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2342 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2343
2344 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002345 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2346 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2347 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2348 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2349 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2350 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2351
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002352- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002353 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2354
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002355 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2356 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2357 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2358 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2359 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2360 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002361
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00002362- Detailed boot stage timing
2363 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
2364 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
2365 of the boot process.
2366
2367 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
2368 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
2369 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
2370 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
2371 the limit, recording will stop.
2372
2373 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
2374 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
2375
2376 Timer summary in microseconds:
2377 Mark Elapsed Stage
2378 0 0 reset
2379 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
2380 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
2381 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
2382 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
2383 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
2384 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
2385 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
2386
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002387Legacy uImage format:
2388
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002389 Arg Where When
2390 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002391 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002392 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002393 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002394 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002395 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002396 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2397 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2398 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002399 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002400 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2401 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2402 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2403 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002404 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002405 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002406
2407 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2408 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2409 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2410 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2411 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2412 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2413 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002414 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002415 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2416 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2417
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002418 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002419
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002420 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd52004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002421 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2422 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002423
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002424 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2425 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2426 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2427 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2428 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2429 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2430 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2431 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2432 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2433 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2434 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2435 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2436 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2437 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2438 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2439 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2440 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2441 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2442 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2443 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2444 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2445 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2446 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2447 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2448 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2449 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2450 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2451 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2452 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2453 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2454 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2455 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2456 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2457 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2458 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2459 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2460 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2461 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2462 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2463 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2464 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2465 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2466 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2467 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2468 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2469 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2470 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002471
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002472 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002473
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002474 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002475 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2476 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00002477
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002478 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
2479 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002480 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002481 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
2482 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2483 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002484 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2485 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002486 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002487
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002488FIT uImage format:
2489
2490 Arg Where When
2491 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2492 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2493 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2494 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2495 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2496 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002497 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002498 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2499 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2500 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2501 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2502 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002503 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2504 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002505 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2506 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2507 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2508 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2509 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2510 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2511 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2512 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2513
2514 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2515 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2516 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002517 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002518 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2519 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2520 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2521 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2522 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2523 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2524 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2525 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2526 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2527 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2528 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2529 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2530
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002531 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002532 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2533
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002534 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002535 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2536
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002537 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002538 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2539
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002540- Standalone program support:
2541 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2542
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002543 This option defines a board specific value for the
2544 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2545 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002546 settings.
2547
2548- Frame Buffer Address:
2549 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2550
2551 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
2552 address for frame buffer.
2553 Then system will reserve the frame buffer address to
2554 defined address instead of lcd_setmem (this function
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002555 grabs the memory for frame buffer by panel's size).
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002556
2557 Please see board_init_f function.
2558
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002559- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2560 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2561 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2562 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2563
2564 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2565 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2566
2567- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
2568 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
2569
2570 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
2571 Needed for mtdparts command support.
2572
2573 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
2574
2575 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
2576 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
2577
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002578- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002579 CONFIG_SPL
2580 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002581
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002582 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2583 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
2584
2585 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
2586 Maximum binary size (text, data and rodata) of the SPL binary.
2587
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002588 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2589 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002590
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002591 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
2592 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
2593
2594 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
2595 Maximum binary size of the BSS section of the SPL binary.
2596
2597 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
2598 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
2599
2600 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
2601 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
2602
2603 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
2604 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002605
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07002606 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
2607 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
2608 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
2609 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
2610
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07002611 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
2612 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
2613 about the running system.
2614
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002615 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
2616 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002617
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002618 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
2619 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002620
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002621 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
2622 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002623
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002624 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
2625 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002626
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002627 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
2628 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002629
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002630 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
2631 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
2632 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
2633 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
2634 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
2635
2636 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
2637 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
2638
2639 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
2640 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
2641
2642 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
2643 Support for drivers/mtd/nand/libnand.o in SPL binary
2644
2645 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
2646 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
2647 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
2648 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
2649 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
2650 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
2651 to read U-Boot with CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
2652
2653 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
2654 Location in NAND for CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE to read U-Boot
2655 from.
2656
2657 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
2658 Location in memory for CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE to load U-Boot
2659 to.
2660
2661 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
2662 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
2663 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
2664
2665 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
2666 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
2667 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
2668
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002669 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
2670 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002671
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002672 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
2673 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002674
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002675 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
2676 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002677
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02002678 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
2679 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
2680
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002681 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
2682 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002683
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002684Modem Support:
2685--------------
2686
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02002687[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002688
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002689- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002690 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
2691
2692- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
2693 CONFIG_HWFLOW
2694
2695- Modem debug support:
2696 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
2697
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002698 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
2699 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002700
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002701- Interrupt support (PPC):
2702
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002703 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2704 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002705 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002706 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002707 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002708 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002709 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002710 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2711 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2712 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002713
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002714- General:
2715
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002716 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
2717 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
2718 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002719 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002720 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
2721 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
2722 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002723
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002724 If there are no modem init strings in the
2725 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
2726 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002727 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002728
2729 See also: doc/README.Modem
2730
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00002731Board initialization settings:
2732------------------------------
2733
2734During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
2735to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
2736before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
2737following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
2738architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
2739typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
2740
2741- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
2742- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
2743- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
2744- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002745
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002746Configuration Settings:
2747-----------------------
2748
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002749- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002750 undefine this when you're short of memory.
2751
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06002752- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
2753 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
2754
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002755- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002756 prompt for user input.
2757
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002758- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002759
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002760- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002761
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002762- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002763
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002764- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002765 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
2766 booted
2767
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002768- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002769 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
2770
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002771- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002772 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002773
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002774- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002775 If the board specific function
2776 extern int overwrite_console (void);
2777 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002778 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
2779
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002780- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002781 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002782
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002783- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002784 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
2785
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002786- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002787 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
2788 simple memory test.
2789
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002790- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002791 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002792
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002793- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00002794 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
2795 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
2796
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002797- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
2798 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002799 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002800 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002801 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
2802 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
2803 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002804 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002805 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002806 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002807
2808 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
2809 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
2810 be touched.
2811
2812 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
2813 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
2814 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
2815 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
2816 problems.
2817
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002818- CONFIG_SYS_TFTP_LOADADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002819 Default load address for network file downloads
2820
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002821- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002822 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
2823
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002824- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002825 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
2826
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002827- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002828 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
2829 Cogent motherboard)
2830
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002831- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002832 Physical start address of Flash memory.
2833
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002834- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002835 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
2836 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02002837 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002838 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002839
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002840- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002841 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
2842 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
2843 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
2844 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002845
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002846- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002847 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
2848
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002849- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002850 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
2851 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002852 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002853 to adjust this setting to your needs.
2854
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002855- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002856 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
2857 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02002858 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
2859 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
2860 enviroment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
2861 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002862 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00002863 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
2864 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
2865 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002866
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06002867- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
2868 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
2869 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
2870 is enabled.
2871
2872- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
2873 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
2874 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2875
2876- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
2877 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
2878 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2879
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002880- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002881 Max number of Flash memory banks
2882
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002883- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002884 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
2885
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002886- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002887 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
2888
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002889- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002890 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
2891
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002892- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002893 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
2894
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002895- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002896 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
2897
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002898- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002899 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
2900 instead of U-Boot software protection.
2901
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002902- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002903
2904 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
2905 without this option such a download has to be
2906 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
2907 copy from RAM to flash.
2908
2909 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
2910 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002911 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
2912 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002913 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
2914
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002915- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002916 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002917 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
2918
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02002919- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002920 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
2921 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002922
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01002923- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
2924 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
2925 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
2926 to the MTD layer.
2927
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002928- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02002929 Use buffered writes to flash.
2930
2931- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
2932 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
2933 write commands.
2934
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002935- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01002936 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
2937 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
2938 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
2939 optionally available.
2940
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05002941- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
2942 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
2943 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
2944 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
2945
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002946- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002947 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
2948 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002949 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
2950 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002951 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002952 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
2953
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002954- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
2955
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02002956 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
2957 internally to store the environment settings. The default
2958 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
2959 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
2960 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002961
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002962The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
2963of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
2964following configurations:
2965
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00002966- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
2967
2968 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
2969 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
2970
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02002971- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002972
2973 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
2974
2975 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
2976 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
2977 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
2978 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
2979 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
2980 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
2981 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
2982 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
2983 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
2984 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
2985 between U-Boot and the environment.
2986
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002987 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002988
2989 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
2990 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
2991 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
2992 for this sector is given here.
2993
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002994 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002995
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002996 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002997
2998 This is just another way to specify the start address of
2999 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003000 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003001
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003002 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003003
3004 Size of the sector containing the environment.
3005
3006
3007 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
3008 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
3009 the environment.
3010
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003011 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003012
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003013 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003014 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003015 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
3016 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
3017
3018 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
3019 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
3020 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
3021 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
3022 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
3023 updating the environment in flash makes it always
3024 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
3025 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
3026 RAM, your target system will be dead.
3027
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003028 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
3029 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003030
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003031 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003032 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00003033 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003034 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003035
3036BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
3037source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
3038accordingly!
3039
3040
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02003041- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003042
3043 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
3044 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
3045 environment.
3046
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003047 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3048 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003049
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003050 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003051 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
3052 can just be read and written to, without any special
3053 provision.
3054
3055BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
3056in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003057console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003058U-Boot will hang.
3059
3060Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
3061environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
3062keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
3063to save the current settings.
3064
3065
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02003066- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003067
3068 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
3069 device and a driver for it.
3070
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003071 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3072 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003073
3074 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
3075 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
3076
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003077 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003078 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
3079 The default address is zero.
3080
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003081 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003082 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
3083 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
3084 would require six bits.
3085
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003086 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003087 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003088 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003089
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003090 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003091 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
3092 that this is NOT the chip address length!
3093
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003094 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003095 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
3096 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
3097 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
3098 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
3099 byte chips.
3100
3101 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
3102 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
3103 in the chip address.
3104
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003105 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003106 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
3107
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003108 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
3109 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
3110 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
3111
3112 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
3113 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
3114 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
3115 EEPROM. For example:
3116
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +02003117 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS "pca9547:70:d\0"
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003118
3119 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
3120 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003121
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003122- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003123
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003124 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003125 want to use for the environment.
3126
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003127 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3128 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3129 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003130
3131 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
3132 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
3133 at the specified address.
3134
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003135- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
3136
3137 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
3138 want to use for the local device's environment.
3139
3140 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3141 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
3142
3143 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
3144 environment area within the remote memory space. The
3145 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003146 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003147
3148BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
3149"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003150environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3151but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003152
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003153- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003154
3155 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
3156 for the environment.
3157
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003158 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3159 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003160
3161 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003162 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
3163 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003164
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003165 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003166
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003167 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003168 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
3169 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003170 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003171 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003172
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003173 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
3174
3175 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
3176 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
3177 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
3178 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
3179 the range to be avoided.
3180
3181 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
3182
3183 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
3184 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
3185 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
3186 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
3187 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003188
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003189- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3190
3191 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3192 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3193 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3194
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003195- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003196
3197 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
3198 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
3199 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
3200 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
3201 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
3202 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
3203 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
3204
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07003205Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003206has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02003207created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003208until then to read environment variables.
3209
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003210The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
3211is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
3212with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
3213necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
3214"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
3215have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003216
3217Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
3218the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003219use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003220
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003221- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003222 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003223
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003224 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003225 also needs to be defined.
3226
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003227- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003228 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003229
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08003230- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
3231 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
3232 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
3233 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
3234 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
3235 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
3236
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003237Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00003238---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003239
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003240- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003241 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
3242
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003243- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003244 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00003245
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003246 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
3247 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
3248 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003249
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003250- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
3251 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
3252 PowerPC SOCs.
3253
3254- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
3255 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
3256 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
3257
3258 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
3259 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
3260
3261- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
3262 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
3263 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003264 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003265 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
3266 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
3267 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
3268
3269 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
3270 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
3271
3272- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003273 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
3274 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003275 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3276 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3277
3278- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
3279 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
3280 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3281 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3282
3283- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
3284 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
3285 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
3286
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003287- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003288 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003289
3290 the default drive number (default value 0)
3291
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003292 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003293
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003294 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003295 (default value 1)
3296
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003297 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003298
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003299 defines the offset of register from address. It
3300 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003301 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003302
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003303 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
3304 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003305 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003306
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003307 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003308 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
3309 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
3310 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
3311 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003312
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003313- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
3314 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
3315 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
3316 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
3317 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
3318 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
3319 is requierd.
3320
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003321- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003322 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00003323 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003324
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003325- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003326
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00003327 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003328 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
3329 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
3330 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
3331 will become available only after programming the
3332 memory controller and running certain initialization
3333 sequences.
3334
3335 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
3336 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
3337 - MPC824X: data cache
3338 - PPC4xx: data cache
3339
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003340- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003341
3342 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003343 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3344 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003345 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003346 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003347 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
3348 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3349 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003350
3351 Note:
3352 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3353 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003354 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003355 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3356 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3357
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003358- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003359
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003360- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003361
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003362- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003363
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003364- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003365
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003366- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003367
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003368- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003369
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003370- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003371 SDRAM timing
3372
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003373- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003374 periodic timer for refresh
3375
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003376- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003377
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003378- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3379 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3380 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3381 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003382 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3383
3384- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003385 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3386 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003387 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3388
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003389- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
3390 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003391 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
3392 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
3393
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003394- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003395 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3396 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
3397
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003398- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01003399 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3400 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
3401
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003402- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003403 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3404 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
3405
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003406- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003407 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
3408 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
3409 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
3410
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003411- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003412 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
3413 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
3414 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
3415 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00003416
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003417- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3418 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
3419 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
3420 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3421 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
3422 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
3423 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
3424 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003425 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00003426
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01003427- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
3428 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
3429 required.
3430
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003431- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
3432 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
3433 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
3434 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
3435 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
3436 by coreboot or similar.
3437
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003438- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3439 Chip has SRIO or not
3440
3441- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3442 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3443
3444- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3445 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3446
3447- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3448 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3449
3450- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3451 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3452
3453- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3454 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3455
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003456- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_16
3457 Defined to tell the NDFC that the NAND chip is using a
3458 16 bit bus.
3459
3460- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3461 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3462 a default value will be used.
3463
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003464- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003465 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3466 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3467
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003468 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3469 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3470
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003471- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003472 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3473 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3474 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003475
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003476- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3477 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3478 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3479 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3480 header files or board specific files.
3481
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003482- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3483 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3484
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003485- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003486 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3487 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003488
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003489- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
3490 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
3491
3492- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
3493 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00003494 to the given FEC; i. e.
3495 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003496 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
3497
3498 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
3499
3500- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
3501 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
3502 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
3503
3504- CONFIG_RMII
3505 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3506 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3507 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3508
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003509- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3510 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3511 The syntax is:
3512
3513 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3514
3515 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3516 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3517 area should have.
3518
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003519- CONFIG_LOOPW
3520 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003521 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003522
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003523- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3524 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3525 "md/mw" commands.
3526 Examples:
3527
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003528 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003529 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3530
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003531 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003532 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3533
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003534 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003535 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003536
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003537- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003538 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003539 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3540 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3541 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003542
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003543 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3544 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3545 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3546 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003547
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003548- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003549 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3550 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3551 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003552
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00003553- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
3554 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
3555 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
3556 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
3557 conditions but may increase the binary size.
3558
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003559Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
3560-----------------------------------
3561
3562The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
3563loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
3564This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3565are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3566within that device.
3567
3568- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_ADDR
3569 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
3570 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3571 is also specified.
3572
3573- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
3574 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
3575 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
3576 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
3577 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
3578
3579- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
3580 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
3581 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
3582 virtual address in NOR flash.
3583
3584- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
3585 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
3586 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
3587
3588- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
3589 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
3590 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3591
3592- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
3593 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
3594 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3595
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00003596- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
3597 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
3598 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003599 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
3600 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
3601 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003602
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003603Building the Software:
3604======================
3605
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003606Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3607and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3608all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3609(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3610recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3611which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003612
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003613If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3614have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3615you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3616Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3617necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003618
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003619 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3620 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003621
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003622Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3623 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3624 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3625 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3626
3627 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3628
3629 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3630 be executed on computers running Windows.
3631
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003632U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3633sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003634is done by typing:
3635
3636 make NAME_config
3637
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003638where "NAME_config" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003639rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003640
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003641Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3642 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3643 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3644 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003645 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003646
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003647 make TQM823L_config
3648 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003649
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003650 make TQM823L_LCD_config
3651 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003652
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003653 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003654
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003655
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003656Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
3657images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003658
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003659- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
3660- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
3661- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003662
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003663By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
3664in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
3665this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
3666
36671. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
3668
3669 make O=/tmp/build distclean
3670 make O=/tmp/build NAME_config
3671 make O=/tmp/build all
3672
36732. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
3674
3675 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
3676 make distclean
3677 make NAME_config
3678 make all
3679
3680Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
3681variable.
3682
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003683
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003684Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
3685for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
3686native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003687
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003688
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003689If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
3690to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
3691steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003692
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000036931. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003694 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
3695 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000036962. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
3697 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
3698 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
36993. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
3700 your board
37013. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
3702 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
37034. Run "make <board>_config" with your new name.
37045. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
3705 to be installed on your target system.
37066. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
3707 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003708
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003709
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003710Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
3711==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003712
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003713If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
3714or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003715provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
3716the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003717official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003718
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003719But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
3720cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003721the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
3722just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003723for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
3724select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
3725environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
3726you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003727
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003728 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003729
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003730or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003731
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003732 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003733
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003734When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
3735U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
3736setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
3737built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
3738<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
3739location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
3740variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003741
3742 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
3743 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
3744 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
3745
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003746With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
3747log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
3748during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003749
3750
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003751See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003752
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003753
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003754Monitor Commands - Overview:
3755============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003756
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003757go - start application at address 'addr'
3758run - run commands in an environment variable
3759bootm - boot application image from memory
3760bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00003761bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003762tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
3763 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
3764 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00003765tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003766rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
3767diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
3768loads - load S-Record file over serial line
3769loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
3770md - memory display
3771mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
3772nm - memory modify (constant address)
3773mw - memory write (fill)
3774cp - memory copy
3775cmp - memory compare
3776crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05003777i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003778sspi - SPI utility commands
3779base - print or set address offset
3780printenv- print environment variables
3781setenv - set environment variables
3782saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
3783protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
3784erase - erase FLASH memory
3785flinfo - print FLASH memory information
3786bdinfo - print Board Info structure
3787iminfo - print header information for application image
3788coninfo - print console devices and informations
3789ide - IDE sub-system
3790loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003791loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003792mtest - simple RAM test
3793icache - enable or disable instruction cache
3794dcache - enable or disable data cache
3795reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
3796echo - echo args to console
3797version - print monitor version
3798help - print online help
3799? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003800
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003801
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003802Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
3803========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003804
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003805TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003806
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003807For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003808
3809
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003810Environment Variables:
3811======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003812
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003813U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
3814can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003815
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003816Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
3817"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
3818without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
3819environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
3820working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
3821environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003822
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003823Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
3824
3825List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003826
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003827 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003828
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003829 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003830
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003831 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003832
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003833 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003834
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003835 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003836
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003837 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3838 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3839 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
3840 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
3841 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
3842 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003843 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
3844 bootm_mapsize.
3845
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003846 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003847 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
3848 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
3849 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
3850 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
3851 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
3852 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003853
3854 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3855 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3856 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
3857 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
3858 environment variable.
3859
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02003860 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
3861 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
3862 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
3863
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003864 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
3865 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
3866 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
3867 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003868
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003869 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
3870 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
3871 be automatically started (by internally calling
3872 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003873
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003874 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
3875 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
3876 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
3877 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
3878 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003879
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003880 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
3881 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00003882 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
3883 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
3884 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
3885 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
3886 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
3887 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
3888 access it during the boot procedure.
3889
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003890 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
3891 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
3892 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
3893 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
3894 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
3895 must be accessible by the kernel.
3896
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00003897 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
3898 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
3899 defined.
3900
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00003901 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
3902 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
3903 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
3904 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
3905 it must be saved and board must be reset.
3906
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003907 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
3908 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
3909 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
3910 is usually what you want since it allows for
3911 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
3912 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003913 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003914 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
3915 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
3916 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
3917 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003918
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003919 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
3920 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
3921 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
3922 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
3923 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
3924 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003925
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003926 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003927
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003928 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
3929 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
3930 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
3931 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
3932 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
3933 boot time on your system, but requires that this
3934 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00003935
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003936 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003937
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003938 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
3939 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003940
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003941 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003942
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003943 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00003944
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003945 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003946
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003947 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003948
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003949 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003950
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003951 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003952
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003953 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
3954 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003955
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02003956 => setenv ethact FEC
3957 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
3958 => setenv ethact SCC
3959 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003960
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01003961 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
3962 available network interfaces.
3963 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
3964
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003965 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003966 either succeed or fail without retrying.
3967 When set to "once" the network operation will
3968 fail when all the available network interfaces
3969 are tried once without success.
3970 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
3971 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003972
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01003973 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01003974
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003975 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003976 UDP source port.
3977
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003978 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
3979 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
3980
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003981 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
3982 we use the TFTP server's default block size
3983
3984 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
3985 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
3986 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
3987 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
3988 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
3989 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
3990 with unreliable TFTP servers.
3991
3992 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003993 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003994 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003995
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00003996The following image location variables contain the location of images
3997used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
3998not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
3999variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
4000server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
4001loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
4002flash or offset in NAND flash.
4003
4004*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
4005boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
4006boards use these variables for other purposes.
4007
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004008Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
4009----- --------- ----------- --------------
4010u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
4011Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
4012device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
4013ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004014
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004015The following environment variables may be used and automatically
4016updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
4017depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004018
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004019 bootfile - see above
4020 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
4021 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
4022 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
4023 hostname - Target hostname
4024 ipaddr - see above
4025 netmask - Subnet Mask
4026 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
4027 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004028
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004029
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004030There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004031
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004032 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
4033 as type string and/or serial number
4034 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004035
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004036These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
4037the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
4038once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004039
4040
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004041Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004042
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004043 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
4044 with the "version" command. This variable is
4045 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004046
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004047
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004048Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
4049only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004050
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004051
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004052Command Line Parsing:
4053=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004054
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004055There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
4056the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004057
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004058Old, simple command line parser:
4059--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004060
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004061- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
4062- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004063- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004064- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
4065 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004066 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004067- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
4068 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004069
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004070Hush shell:
4071-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004072
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004073- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
4074 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
4075 until...do...done, ...
4076- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
4077 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
4078 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
4079 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004080
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004081General rules:
4082--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004083
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004084(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
4085 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
4086 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
4087 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004088
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004089(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004090 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004091 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
4092 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004093
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004094Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
4095=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004096
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004097Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004098such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
4099"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004100
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004101Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
4102MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
4103"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004104
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004105If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
4106in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
4107ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
4108variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004109
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004110o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
4111 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004112
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004113o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
4114 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
4115 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004116
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004117o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
4118 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004119
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004120o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
4121 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
4122 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004123
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004124o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
4125 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004126
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004127If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004128will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004129may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
4130The naming convention is as follows:
4131"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004132
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004133Image Formats:
4134==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004135
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01004136U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
4137images in two formats:
4138
4139New uImage format (FIT)
4140-----------------------
4141
4142Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
4143to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
4144components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
4145SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
4146
4147
4148Old uImage format
4149-----------------
4150
4151Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
4152preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
4153details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004154
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004155* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
4156 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05004157 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
4158 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
4159 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02004160* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004161 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
4162 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004163* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
4164* Load Address
4165* Entry Point
4166* Image Name
4167* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004168
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004169The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
4170and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
4171CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004172
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004173
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004174Linux Support:
4175==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004176
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004177Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
4178easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
4179U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004180
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004181U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
4182special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
4183"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
4184instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
4185serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004186
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004187- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
4188 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
4189 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004190
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004191- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
4192 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004193
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004194- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
4195 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
4196 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
4197 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
4198 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
4199 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004200
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004201
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004202Linux HOWTO:
4203============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004204
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004205Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
4206---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004207
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004208U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
4209configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
4210(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
4211Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004212
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004213But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004214
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004215Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
4216include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02004217Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
4218and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004219as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004220
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004221
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004222Configuring the Linux kernel:
4223-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004224
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004225No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
4226device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004227
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004228
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004229Building a Linux Image:
4230-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004231
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004232With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
4233not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
4234"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
4235U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
4236which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
4237100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004238
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004239Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004240
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004241 make TQM850L_config
4242 make oldconfig
4243 make dep
4244 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004245
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004246The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
4247encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
4248CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004249
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004250* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004251
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004252* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004253
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004254 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
4255 -R .note -R .comment \
4256 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004257
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004258* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004259
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004260 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004261
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004262* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004263
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004264 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
4265 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
4266 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004267
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004268
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004269The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
4270with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
4271combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
4272byte header containing information about target architecture,
4273operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
4274stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004275
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004276"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
4277print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004278
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004279In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
4280contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
4281checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004282
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004283 tools/mkimage -l image
4284 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004285
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004286The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
4287from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004288
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004289 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
4290 -n name -d data_file image
4291 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
4292 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
4293 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4294 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
4295 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
4296 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
4297 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
4298 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004299
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00004300Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
4301address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
4302kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004303
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004304- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
4305- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004306
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004307So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004308
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004309 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4310 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004311 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004312 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
4313 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4314 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4315 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4316 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4317 Load Address: 0x00000000
4318 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004319
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004320To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004321
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004322 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
4323 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4324 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4325 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4326 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4327 Load Address: 0x00000000
4328 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004329
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004330NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
4331speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
4332needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
4333need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004334
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004335 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004336 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4337 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004338 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004339 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
4340 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4341 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4342 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
4343 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
4344 Load Address: 0x00000000
4345 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004346
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004347
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004348Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
4349when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004350
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004351 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
4352 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
4353 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
4354 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4355 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
4356 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4357 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
4358 Load Address: 0x00000000
4359 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004360
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004361
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004362Installing a Linux Image:
4363-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004364
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004365To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
4366you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004367
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004368 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004369
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004370The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
4371image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
4372address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
4373specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
4374command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004375
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004376Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
4377TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004378
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004379 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004380
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004381 .......... done
4382 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004383
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004384 => loads 40100000
4385 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4386 ~>examples/image.srec
4387 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
4388 ...
4389 15989 15990 15991 15992
4390 [file transfer complete]
4391 [connected]
4392 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004393
4394
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004395You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004396this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004397corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004398
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004399 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004400
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004401 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4402 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4403 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4404 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4405 Load Address: 00000000
4406 Entry Point: 0000000c
4407 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004408
4409
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004410Boot Linux:
4411-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004412
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004413The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4414memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4415of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4416parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4417"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004418
4419
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004420 => printenv bootargs
4421 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004422
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004423 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004424
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004425 => printenv bootargs
4426 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004427
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004428 => bootm 40020000
4429 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4430 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4431 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4432 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4433 Load Address: 00000000
4434 Entry Point: 0000000c
4435 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4436 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4437 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4438 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4439 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4440 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4441 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4442 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004443
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004444If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004445the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4446format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004447
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004448 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004449
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004450 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4451 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4452 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4453 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4454 Load Address: 00000000
4455 Entry Point: 0000000c
4456 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004457
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004458 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4459 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4460 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4461 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4462 Load Address: 00000000
4463 Entry Point: 00000000
4464 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004465
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004466 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4467 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4468 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4469 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4470 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4471 Load Address: 00000000
4472 Entry Point: 0000000c
4473 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4474 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4475 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4476 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4477 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4478 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4479 Load Address: 00000000
4480 Entry Point: 00000000
4481 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4482 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4483 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4484 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4485 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4486 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4487 ...
4488 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4489 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004490
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004491 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004492
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004493Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4494-----------
4495
4496First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4497titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4498following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4499flat device tree:
4500
4501=> print oftaddr
4502oftaddr=0x300000
4503=> print oft
4504oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4505=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4506Speed: 1000, full duplex
4507Using TSEC0 device
4508TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4509Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4510Load address: 0x300000
4511Loading: #
4512done
4513Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4514=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4515Speed: 1000, full duplex
4516Using TSEC0 device
4517TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4518Filename 'uImage'.
4519Load address: 0x200000
4520Loading:############
4521done
4522Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4523=> print loadaddr
4524loadaddr=200000
4525=> print oftaddr
4526oftaddr=0x300000
4527=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4528## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004529 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4530 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4531 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004532 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004533 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004534 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4535 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4536Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4537Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4538Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4539[snip]
4540
4541
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004542More About U-Boot Image Types:
4543------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004544
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004545U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004546
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004547 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4548 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4549 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4550 the Standalone Program.
4551 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4552 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4553 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4554 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4555 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4556 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4557 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4558 being started.
4559 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4560 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4561 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4562 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4563 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4564 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004565
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004566 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4567 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4568 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4569 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4570 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4571 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004572
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004573 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4574 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4575 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004576
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004577 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4578 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4579 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4580 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004581
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004582Booting the Linux zImage:
4583-------------------------
4584
4585On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
4586using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
4587as the syntax of "bootm" command.
4588
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00004589Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_INITRD_RAW allows user to supply
4590kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
4591address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
4592format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
4593
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004594
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004595Standalone HOWTO:
4596=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004597
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004598One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4599run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4600U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004601
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004602Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004603
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004604"Hello World" Demo:
4605-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004606
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004607'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4608application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4609It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4610like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004611
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004612 => loads
4613 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4614 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
4615 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4616 [file transfer complete]
4617 [connected]
4618 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004619
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004620 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
4621 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4622 Hello World
4623 argc = 7
4624 argv[0] = "40004"
4625 argv[1] = "Hello"
4626 argv[2] = "World!"
4627 argv[3] = "This"
4628 argv[4] = "is"
4629 argv[5] = "a"
4630 argv[6] = "test."
4631 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
4632 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004633
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004634 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004635
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004636Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
4637handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
4638Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
4639The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
4640character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
4641controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004642
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004643 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
4644 b - enable interrupts and start timer
4645 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
4646 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004647
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004648 => loads
4649 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4650 ~>examples/timer.srec
4651 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4652 [file transfer complete]
4653 [connected]
4654 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004655
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004656 => go 40004
4657 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4658 TIMERS=0xfff00980
4659 Using timer 1
4660 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004661
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004662Hit 'b':
4663 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
4664 Enabling timer
4665Hit '?':
4666 [q, b, e, ?] ........
4667 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
4668Hit '?':
4669 [q, b, e, ?] .
4670 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
4671Hit '?':
4672 [q, b, e, ?] .
4673 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
4674Hit '?':
4675 [q, b, e, ?] .
4676 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
4677Hit 'e':
4678 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
4679Hit 'q':
4680 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004681
4682
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004683Minicom warning:
4684================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004685
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004686Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
4687"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
4688consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
4689Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
4690especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00004691use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
4692http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
4693for help with kermit.
4694
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004695
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004696Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
4697configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004698
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004699 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
4700 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
4701 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004702
4703
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004704NetBSD Notes:
4705=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004706
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004707Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
4708(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004709
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004710Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
4711NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
4712need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
4713Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
4714attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
4715missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004716
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004717 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
4718 # mkdir powerpc
4719 # ln -s powerpc machine
4720 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
4721 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004722
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004723Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
4724and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004725
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004726Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
4727stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
4728proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
4729tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00004730meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004731
4732
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004733Implementation Internals:
4734=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004735
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004736The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
4737implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
4738inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
4739hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004740
4741
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004742Initial Stack, Global Data:
4743---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004744
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004745The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
4746starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
4747system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
4748This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
4749is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
4750at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
4751options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
4752models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
4753MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
4754locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004755
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004756 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004757 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004758
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004759 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
4760 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
4761 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
4762 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004763
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004764 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
4765 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
4766 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
4767 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
4768 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004769 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004770 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
4771 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004772
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004773 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
4774 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004775 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004776 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
4777 board designers haven't used it for something that would
4778 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
4779 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004780
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004781 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004782 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
4783 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02004784 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004785 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
4786 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
4787 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
4788 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
4789 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004790
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004791 -Chris Hallinan
4792 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004793
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004794It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
4795code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004796
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004797* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
4798 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004799
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004800* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004801 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
4802 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004803
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004804* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
4805 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004806
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004807Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
4808normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
4809turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
4810simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
4811functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
4812functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
4813the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
4814place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
4815reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004816
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004817When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
4818relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
4819GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004820
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004821For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
4822 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004823 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004824 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
4825 R5-R10: parameter passing
4826 R13: small data area pointer
4827 R30: GOT pointer
4828 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004829
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01004830 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
4831 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
4832 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004833
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004834 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004835
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004836 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
4837 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
4838 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
4839 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
4840 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
4841 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004842
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00004843On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05004844 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
4845
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00004846 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05004847
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004848On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004849
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004850 R0: function argument word/integer result
4851 R1-R3: function argument word
4852 R9: GOT pointer
4853 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking if enabled)
4854 R11: argument (frame) pointer
4855 R12: temporary workspace
4856 R13: stack pointer
4857 R14: link register
4858 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004859
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004860 ==> U-Boot will use R8 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004861
Thomas Chou0df01fd2010-05-21 11:08:03 +08004862On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
4863 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
4864
4865 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
4866
4867 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
4868 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
4869
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004870On NDS32, the following registers are used:
4871
4872 R0-R1: argument/return
4873 R2-R5: argument
4874 R15: temporary register for assembler
4875 R16: trampoline register
4876 R28: frame pointer (FP)
4877 R29: global pointer (GP)
4878 R30: link register (LP)
4879 R31: stack pointer (SP)
4880 PC: program counter (PC)
4881
4882 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
4883
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02004884NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
4885or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004886
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004887Memory Management:
4888------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004889
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004890U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
4891MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004892
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004893The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
4894controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
4895memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
4896physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004897
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004898U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
4899TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
4900booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
4901to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004902memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004903configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
4904Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004905
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004906Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
4907of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004908
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004909So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
4910this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004911
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004912 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
4913 :
4914 0x0000 1FFF
4915 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
4916 :
4917 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004918
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004919 :
4920 :
4921 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
4922 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
4923 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
4924 :
4925 0x00FD FFFF
4926 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
4927 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
4928 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
4929 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004930
4931
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004932System Initialization:
4933----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004934
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004935In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004936(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004937configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
4938To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
4939To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
4940initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
4941which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
4942part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
4943the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004944
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004945Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
4946preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
4947(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
4948on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
4949programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
4950simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
4951banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004952
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004953When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
4954different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
4955bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
49560x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
4957contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004958
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004959Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
4960and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
4961Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
4962pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004963
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004964Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
4965until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
4966running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
4967new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004968
4969
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004970U-Boot Porting Guide:
4971----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004972
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004973[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
4974list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004975
4976
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004977int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004978{
4979 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004980
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004981 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
4982 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004983
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004984 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004985 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004986 return 0;
4987 }
4988
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004989 Download latest U-Boot source;
4990
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004991 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004992
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004993 if (clueless)
4994 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004995
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004996 while (learning) {
4997 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004998 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
4999 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005000 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005001 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005002 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005003
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005004 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
5005 Buy a BDI3000;
5006 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005007 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005008
5009 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
5010 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
5011 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
5012 } else {
5013 Create your own board support subdirectory;
5014 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005015 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005016 Edit new board/<myboard> files
5017 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005018
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005019 while (!accepted) {
5020 while (!running) {
5021 do {
5022 Add / modify source code;
5023 } until (compiles);
5024 Debug;
5025 if (clueless)
5026 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
5027 }
5028 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
5029 if (reasonable critiques)
5030 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
5031 else
5032 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005033 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005034
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005035 return 0;
5036}
5037
5038void no_more_time (int sig)
5039{
5040 hire_a_guru();
5041}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005042
5043
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005044Coding Standards:
5045-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005046
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005047All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005048coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005049"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005050
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005051Source files originating from a different project (for example the
5052MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
5053reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
5054sources.
5055
5056Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
5057Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
5058in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005059
5060Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
5061- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005062- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005063- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005064- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005065- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
5066
5067Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
5068with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005069
5070
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005071Submitting Patches:
5072-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005073
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005074Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
5075establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
5076may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005077
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02005078Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005079
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005080Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
5081see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
5082
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005083When you send a patch, please include the following information with
5084it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005085
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005086* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
5087 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
5088 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005089
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005090* For new features: a description of the feature and your
5091 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005092
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005093* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
5094
5095* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
5096
5097* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add this
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005098 board to the MAINTAINERS file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005099
5100* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
5101 document these in the README file.
5102
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005103* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
5104 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005105 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005106 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
5107 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005108
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005109 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
5110 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
5111 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005112
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005113 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
5114 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
5115 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
5116 affected files).
5117
5118 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
5119 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005120
5121* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
5122 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
5123
5124* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
5125 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
5126
5127
5128Notes:
5129
5130* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
5131 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
5132 for any of the boards.
5133
5134* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
5135 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
5136 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
5137
5138* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
5139 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
5140 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
5141 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
5142 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
5143 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00005144
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005145* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
5146 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
5147 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
5148 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.